blob: 7f17fe8b8cc2dc98d6e18ac81b2c0b79951e31a0 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000028#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000029#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000031#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000032#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000033#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000034#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000035#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000036#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
330} // unnamed namespace
331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000382
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000391
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398 return RC;
399}
400
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000401static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416}
417
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000418comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432}
433
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000434comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000437}
438
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000439comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000443 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000445
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000451 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000454 return CFC;
455 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000456 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000457 }
458
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000470 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000476 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000479 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000485 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000500 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000501 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000504 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000519 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000531 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000532 }
533
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000540
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000544}
545
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000546void
547ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584}
585
586TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000630 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000659 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675}
676
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000677CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000679
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000686 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000688 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
689 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000690 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000691}
692
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000693static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000694 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
695 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
696 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
697 // language-specific address space.
698 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
699 1, // opencl_global
700 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000701 3, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000702 4, // opencl_generic
703 5, // cuda_device
704 6, // cuda_constant
705 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000706 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000707 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000708 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000709 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000710 }
711}
712
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000713static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
714 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
715 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000716 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
717 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
718 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
719 return true;
720 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
721 return false;
722 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000723 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000724}
725
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000726ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000727 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000728 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000729 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
730 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
732 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
733 UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
734 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
735 ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
736 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
737 FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
738 ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr),
739 BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
Nico Weber227822e2015-01-04 05:29:21 +0000740 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000741 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova0416102014-11-11 01:26:14 +0000742 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFile, SM)),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000743 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
744 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), BuiltinInfo(builtins),
745 DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
746 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
747 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000748 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
749}
750
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000751ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000752 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
753
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000754 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
755 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
756 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000757
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000758 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
759 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
760 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
761 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
762 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
763
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000764 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000765 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
766 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
767 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
768 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
769 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
770 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
771 R->Destroy(*this);
772
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000773 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000779
780 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
781 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
782 A != AEnd; ++A)
783 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000784
Reid Kleckner588c9372014-02-19 23:44:52 +0000785 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000786}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000787
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000788void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
789 if (!AllParents) return;
790 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
791 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
792 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
793 } else {
794 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
795 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
796 }
797 }
798}
799
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000800void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000801 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000802}
803
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000804void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000805ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
806 ExternalSource = Source;
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000807}
808
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000809void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000810 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
811 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000812
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000813 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000814#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000815#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
816#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
817 0 // Extra
818 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000819
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000820 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
821 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000822 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000823 }
824
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000825 unsigned Idx = 0;
826 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
827#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
828 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000829 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
830 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000831 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
832 ++Idx;
833#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
834#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000835
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000836 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
837
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000838 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000839 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
840 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
841 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
842 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
843 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
844 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000845 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000846 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
847 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
848 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
849 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
850 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
851 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000852 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000853 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
854 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
855 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
856 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
857 << NumImplicitDestructors
858 << " implicit destructors created\n";
859
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000860 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000861 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000862 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
863 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000864
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000865 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000866}
867
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000868RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
869 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000870 SourceLocation Loc;
871 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000872 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
873 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
874 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000875 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000876 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
877 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000878 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +0000879 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
880 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000881 return NewDecl;
882}
883
884TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
885 StringRef Name) const {
886 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
887 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
888 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
889 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
890 NewDecl->setImplicit();
891 return NewDecl;
892}
893
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000894TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000895 if (!Int128Decl)
896 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000897 return Int128Decl;
898}
899
900TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000901 if (!UInt128Decl)
902 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000903 return UInt128Decl;
904}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000905
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000906TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
Nico Weber5b0b46f2013-06-21 01:29:36 +0000907 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000908 if (!Float128StubDecl)
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +0000909 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +0000910
Nico Webere1687c52013-06-20 21:44:55 +0000911 return Float128StubDecl;
912}
913
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000914void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000915 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000916 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000917 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000918}
919
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000920void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
921 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
922 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000923 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000924
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000925 this->Target = &Target;
926
927 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
928 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000929 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000930
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000931 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000932 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000933
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000934 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000935 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000936 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000937 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000938 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
939 else
940 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000941 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000942 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
943 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
944 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
945 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
946 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000947
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000948 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000949 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
950 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
951 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
952 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
953 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000954
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000955 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000956 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
957 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
958 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000959
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000960 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
961 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
962 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
963
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000964 // C++ 3.9.1p5
965 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
966 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
967 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
968 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
969 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
970 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
971 else {
972 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
973 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
974 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000975
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000976 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
977
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000978 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
979 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
980 else // C99
981 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
982
983 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
984 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
985 else // C99
986 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
987
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000988 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
989 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
990 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
991 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
992 // expressions.
993 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000994
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000995 // Placeholder type for functions.
996 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
997
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +0000998 // Placeholder type for bound members.
999 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1000
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001001 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1002 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1003
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001004 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1005 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1006
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001007 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1008 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1009
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001010 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1011 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1012
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001013 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001014 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1015 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1016 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001017
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001018 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001019 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1020 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001021 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001022
1023 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1024 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1025 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1026 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1027 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1028 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1029 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001030
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001031 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001032 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001033 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001034
1035 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001036 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1037 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001038
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001039 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001040
1041 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001042
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001043 // void * type
1044 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001045
1046 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1047 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001048
1049 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1050 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001051
1052 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1053 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001054}
1055
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001056DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001057 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1058}
1059
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001060AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1061 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1062 if (!Result) {
1063 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1064 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1065 }
1066
1067 return *Result;
1068}
1069
1070/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1071void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1072 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1073 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1074 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1075 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1076 }
1077}
1078
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001079// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001080MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001081ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001082 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001083 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1084 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1085}
1086
1087ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1088ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1089 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1090 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1091 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1092 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001093
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001094 return Pos->second;
1095}
1096
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001097void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001098ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001099 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1100 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001101 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1102 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001103 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1104 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1105}
1106
1107void
1108ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1109 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1110 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1111 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1112 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001113}
1114
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001115FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1116 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1117 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1118 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001119 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1120 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001121 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001122
1123 return Pos->second;
1124}
1125
1126void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1127 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1128 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1129 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001130 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001131}
1132
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001133NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001134ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001135 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001136 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1137 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001138 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001139
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001140 return Pos->second;
1141}
1142
1143void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001144ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1145 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1146 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1147 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1148 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1149 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1150 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1151}
1152
1153UsingShadowDecl *
1154ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1155 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1156 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1157 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001158 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001159
1160 return Pos->second;
1161}
1162
1163void
1164ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1165 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1166 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1167 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001168}
1169
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001170FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1171 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1172 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1173 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001174 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001175
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001176 return Pos->second;
1177}
1178
1179void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1180 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1181 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1182 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1183 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1184 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001185
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001186 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1187}
1188
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001189ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1190ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1191 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001192 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001193 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001194 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001195
1196 return Pos->second.begin();
1197}
1198
1199ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1200ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1201 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001202 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001203 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001204 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001205
1206 return Pos->second.end();
1207}
1208
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001209unsigned
1210ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1211 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001212 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001213 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1214 return 0;
1215
1216 return Pos->second.size();
1217}
1218
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001219void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1220 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001221 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001222 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1223}
1224
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001225void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1226 const NamedDecl *D,
1227 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001228 assert(D);
1229
1230 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001231 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1232 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001233 return;
1234 }
1235
1236 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1237 if (!Method)
1238 return;
1239
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001240 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1241 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001242 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001243}
1244
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001245void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1246 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1247 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1248 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1249 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1250 LastLocalImport = Import;
1251 return;
1252 }
1253
1254 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1255 LastLocalImport = Import;
1256}
1257
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001258//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1259// Type Sizing and Analysis
1260//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001261
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001262/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1263/// scalar floating point type.
1264const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001265 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001266 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1267 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001268 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001269 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001270 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1271 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1272 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001273 }
1274}
1275
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001276CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001277 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001278
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001279 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1280 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1281 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001282
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001283 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1284 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1285 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1286 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001287 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001288 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1289 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1290 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1291 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1292 } else {
1293 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1294 }
1295 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001296 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1297 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1298 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1299 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001300
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001301 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1302 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001303 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001304 // do nothing
1305
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001306 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001307 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001308 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001309 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001310 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1311 else
1312 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1313 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001314 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1315 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001316 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1317 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001318 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001319 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1320 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001321 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1322 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1323 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1324 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1325 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1326 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001327 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001328 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001329 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1330 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1331 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1332 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001333 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001334
1335 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1336 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1337 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1338 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1339 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001340 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1341 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1342 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1343 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1344 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001345
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001346 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1347 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001348
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001349 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1350 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1351 if (Offset > 0) {
1352 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1353 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1354 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1355 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1356 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1357 }
1358
1359 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001360 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001361 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001362 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001363
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001364 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001365}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001366
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001367// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1368// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1369// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1370// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1371std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1372ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1373 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1374
1375 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1376 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1377 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1378 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1379 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1380 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1381 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1382 }
1383 }
1384
1385 return sizeAndAlign;
1386}
1387
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001388/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1389/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1390std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1391static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1392 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1393 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1394 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1395 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001396 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1397 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001398 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1399 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1400 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001401 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1402 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1403 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001404 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1405 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1406}
1407
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001408std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001409ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001410 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1411 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001412 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1413 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1414 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001415}
1416
1417std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001418ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001419 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1420}
1421
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001422bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1423 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1424}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001425
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001426bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1427 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1428}
1429
1430TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001431 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1432 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1433 return I->second;
1434
1435 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1436 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1437 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001438 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001439}
1440
1441/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1442/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001443///
1444/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1445/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1446/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001447TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1448 uint64_t Width = 0;
1449 unsigned Align = 8;
1450 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001451 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001452#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1453#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001454#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001455#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001456#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1457 case Type::Class: \
1458 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1459 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001460#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001461 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001462
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001463 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1464 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001465 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1466 Width = 0;
1467 Align = 32;
1468 break;
1469
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001470 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001471 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001472 Width = 0;
1473 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1474 break;
1475
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001476 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001477 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001478
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001479 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001480 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001481 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001482 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001483 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1484 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001485 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1486 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1487 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001488 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001489 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001490 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001491 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001492 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001493 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1494 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001495 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001496 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1497 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001498 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001499 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1500 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1501 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001502 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1503 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1504 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1505 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001506 break;
1507 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001508
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001509 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001510 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001511 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001512 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001513 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1514 Width = 0;
1515 Align = 8;
1516 break;
1517
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001518 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001519 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1520 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001521 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001522 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1523 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1524 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001525 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001526 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1527 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001528 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001529 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1530 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001531 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1532 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001533 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001534 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001535 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1536 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001537 break;
1538 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001539 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1540 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001541 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001542 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001543 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001544 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1545 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001546 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001547 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001548 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001549 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1550 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001551 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001552 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001553 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001554 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1555 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001556 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001557 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001558 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001559 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1560 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001561 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001562 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1563 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1564 Width = 128;
1565 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1566 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001567 case BuiltinType::Half:
1568 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1569 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1570 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001571 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001572 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1573 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001574 break;
1575 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001576 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1577 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001578 break;
1579 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001580 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1581 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001582 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001583 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001584 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1585 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001586 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001587 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1588 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1589 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001590 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1591 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001592 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001593 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1594 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1595 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1596 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1597 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001598 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001599 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1600 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1601 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1602 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1603 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1604 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1605 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1606 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1607 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1608 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001609 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001610 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001611 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001612 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1613 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001614 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001615 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001616 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1617 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001618 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1619 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001620 break;
1621 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001622 case Type::LValueReference:
1623 case Type::RValueReference: {
1624 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1625 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001626 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1627 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001628 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1629 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001630 break;
1631 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001632 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001633 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001634 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1635 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001636 break;
1637 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001638 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001639 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001640 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001641 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001642 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001643 case Type::Complex: {
1644 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1645 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001646 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1647 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1648 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001649 break;
1650 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001651 case Type::ObjCObject:
1652 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001653 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001654 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001655 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001656 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001657 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001658 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001659 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001660 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001661 break;
1662 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001663 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001664 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001665 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1666
1667 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001668 Width = 8;
1669 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001670 break;
1671 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001672
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001673 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001674 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1675
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001676 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001677 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001678 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001679 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001680 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001681 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001682
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001683 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001684 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1685 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001686
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001687 case Type::Auto: {
1688 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001689 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1690 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001691 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001692 }
1693
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001694 case Type::Paren:
1695 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1696
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001697 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001698 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001699 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001700 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1701 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1702 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001703 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001704 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001705 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001706 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001707 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001708 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1709 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001710 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001711 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001712 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001713
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001714 case Type::Elaborated:
1715 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001716
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001717 case Type::Attributed:
1718 return getTypeInfo(
1719 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1720
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001721 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001722 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001723 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1724 Width = Info.Width;
1725 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001726
1727 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1728 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1729 // favorable to atomic operations:
1730 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1731 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1732 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1733 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1734
1735 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001736 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1737 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001738 }
1739
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001740 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001741
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001742 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001743 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001744}
1745
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001746/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1747CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1748 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1749}
1750
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001751/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1752int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1753 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1754}
1755
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001756/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1757/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001758CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001759 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001760}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001761CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001762 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001763}
1764
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001765/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001766/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001767CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001768 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001769}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001770CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001771 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001772}
1773
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001774/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1775/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1776/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1777/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001778unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001779 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1780 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001781
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00001782 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1783 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1784
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001785 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
Richard Smithd7e1fe42014-06-10 23:43:44 +00001786 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00001787 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001788 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1789 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001790 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1791 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001792 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1793 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001794 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00001795 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001796
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001797 return ABIAlign;
1798}
1799
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001800/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1801/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1802unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1803 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1804}
1805
1806/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1807/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1808CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1809 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1810}
1811
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001812/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1813/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1814/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1815/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1816/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001817///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001818void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1819 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001820 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001821 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1822 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1823 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00001824 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1825 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001826 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001827 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001828 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001829 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1830 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1831 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001832}
1833
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001834/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1835/// those inherited by it.
1836void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001837 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001838 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001839 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1840 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00001841 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001842 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001843 for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1844 Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1845 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001846 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001847 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001848
1849 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00001850 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1851 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001852
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001853 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1854 while (SD) {
1855 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1856 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1857 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001858 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00001859 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001860 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001861 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1862 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001863 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001864 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001865 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001866 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00001867 for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1868 CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001869 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001870 }
1871}
1872
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001873unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001874 unsigned count = 0;
1875 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00001876 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001877 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001878
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001879 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1880 // includes synthesized ivars.
1881 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001882 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1883
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001884 return count;
1885}
1886
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001887bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1888 if (!E)
1889 return false;
1890
1891 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1892 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1893
1894 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1895 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1896 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1897 return true;
1898
1899 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1900 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1901
1902 return false;
1903}
1904
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001905/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1906ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1907 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1908 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1909 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1910 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001911 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001912}
1913/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1914ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1915 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1916 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1917 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1918 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001919 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001920}
1921
1922/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1923void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1924 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1925 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1926 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1927}
1928/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1929void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1930 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1931 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1932 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1933}
1934
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001935const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1936 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1937 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1938 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001939 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001940 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1941 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001942 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001943 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1944 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001945 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1946
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001947 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001948}
1949
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001950/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1951/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001952Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001953 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1954 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1955 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001956 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001957 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001958 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001959}
1960
1961/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1962void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1963 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001964 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1965 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001966 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1967}
1968
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001969TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001970 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001971 if (!DataSize)
1972 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1973 else
1974 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001975 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001976
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001977 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1978 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1979 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1980 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001981}
1982
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001983TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001984 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001985 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001986 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001987 return DI;
1988}
1989
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001990const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001991ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001992 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001993}
1994
1995const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001996ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1997 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001998 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1999}
2000
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002001//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2002// Type creation/memoization methods
2003//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2004
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002005QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002006ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2007 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2008 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002009
2010 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2011 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002012 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002013 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002014 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2015 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2016 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002017 }
2018
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002019 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2020 QualType canon;
2021 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2022 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002023 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2024 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002025
2026 // Re-find the insert position.
2027 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2028 }
2029
2030 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2031 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2032 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002033}
2034
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002035QualType
2036ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002037 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2038 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002039 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002040
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002041 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2042 // into one ExtQuals node.
2043 QualifierCollector Quals;
2044 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002045
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002046 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2047 // another one.
2048 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2049 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2050 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002051
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002052 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002053}
2054
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002055QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002056 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002057 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002058 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002059 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002060
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002061 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2062 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002063 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002064 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2065 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2066 }
2067 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002068
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002069 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2070 // into one ExtQuals node.
2071 QualifierCollector Quals;
2072 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002073
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002074 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2075 // another one.
2076 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2077 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2078 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002079
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002080 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002081}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002082
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002083const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2084 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2085 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2086 return T;
2087
2088 QualType Result;
2089 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002090 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002091 } else {
2092 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2093 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2094 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002095 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002096 }
2097
2098 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2099}
2100
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002101void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2102 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002103 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2104 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002105 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2106 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002107 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002108 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2109 FD = Next;
2110 else
2111 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002112 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002113 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2114 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002115}
2116
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002117/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2118/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2119/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2120/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2121static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2122 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2123 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2124 // Might have some parens.
2125 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2126 return Context.getParenType(
2127 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2128
2129 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2130 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2131 return Context.getAttributedType(
2132 AT->getAttrKind(),
2133 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2134 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2135 ESI));
2136
2137 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2138 // specification.
2139 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2140 return Context.getFunctionType(
2141 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2142 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2143}
2144
2145void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2146 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2147 bool AsWritten) {
2148 // Update the type.
2149 QualType Updated =
2150 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2151 FD->setType(Updated);
2152
2153 if (!AsWritten)
2154 return;
2155
2156 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2157 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2158 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2159 // the type-as-written too.
2160 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2161 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2162
2163 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2164 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2165 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2166 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2167 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2168 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2169 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2170 }
2171}
2172
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002173/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2174/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002175QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002176 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2177 // structure.
2178 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2179 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002180
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002181 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002182 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2183 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002184
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002185 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2186 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2187 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002188 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002189 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002190
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002191 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2192 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002193 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002194 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002195 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002196 Types.push_back(New);
2197 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2198 return QualType(New, 0);
2199}
2200
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002201/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2202/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002203QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002204 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2205 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002206 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002207 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002208
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002209 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002210 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002211 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002212
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002213 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2214 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002215 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002216 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002217 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002219 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2220 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002221 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002222 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002223 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002224 Types.push_back(New);
2225 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002226 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002227}
2228
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002229QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2230 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2231 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002232 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002233 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2234 if (AT)
2235 return QualType(AT, 0);
2236
2237 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2238
2239 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2240 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002241 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002242
2243 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2244 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2245 Types.push_back(AT);
2246 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2247 return QualType(AT, 0);
2248}
2249
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002250QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2251 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2252
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002253 QualType Decayed;
2254
2255 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2256 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2257 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2258 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2259 // the array type derivation.
2260 if (T->isArrayType())
2261 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2262
2263 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2264 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2265 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2266 // in 6.3.2.1.
2267 if (T->isFunctionType())
2268 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2269
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002270 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2271 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002272 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002273 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2274 if (AT)
2275 return QualType(AT, 0);
2276
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002277 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2278
2279 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002280 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002281 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002282
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002283 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2284 Types.push_back(AT);
2285 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2286 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002287}
2288
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002289/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002290/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002291QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002292 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2293 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002294 // structure.
2295 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2296 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002297
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002298 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002299 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2300 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2301 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002302
2303 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002304 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2305 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002306 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002307 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002309 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2310 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2311 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002312 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002313 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002314 BlockPointerType *New
2315 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002316 Types.push_back(New);
2317 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2318 return QualType(New, 0);
2319}
2320
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002321/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2322/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002323QualType
2324ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002325 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2326 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2327
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002328 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2329 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002330 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002331 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002332
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002333 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002334 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2335 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002336 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002337
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002338 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2339
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002340 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2341 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2342 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002343 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2344 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2345 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002346
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002347 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002348 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2349 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002350 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002351 }
2352
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002353 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002354 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2355 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002356 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002357 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002358
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002359 return QualType(New, 0);
2360}
2361
2362/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2363/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002364QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002365 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2366 // structure.
2367 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002368 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002369
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002370 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002371 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2372 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2373 return QualType(RT, 0);
2374
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002375 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2376
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002377 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2378 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2379 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002380 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2381 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2382 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002383
2384 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2385 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2386 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002387 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002388 }
2389
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002390 RValueReferenceType *New
2391 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002392 Types.push_back(New);
2393 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002394 return QualType(New, 0);
2395}
2396
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002397/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2398/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002399QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002400 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2401 // structure.
2402 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2403 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2404
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002405 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002406 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2407 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2408 return QualType(PT, 0);
2409
2410 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2411 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2412 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002413 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002414 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2415
2416 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2417 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2418 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002419 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002420 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002421 MemberPointerType *New
2422 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002423 Types.push_back(New);
2424 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2425 return QualType(New, 0);
2426}
2427
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002428/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002429/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002430QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002431 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002432 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002433 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002434 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2435 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002436 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2437
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002438 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2439 // the target.
2440 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002441 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002442 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002443
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002444 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002445 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002446
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002447 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002448 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002449 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002450 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002451
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002452 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2453 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2454 QualType Canon;
2455 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2456 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002457 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002458 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002459 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002460
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002461 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002462 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002463 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002464 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002465 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002466
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002467 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002468 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002469 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002470 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002471 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002472}
2473
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002474/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2475/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2476/// sizes replaced with [*].
2477QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2478 // Vastly most common case.
2479 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002480
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002481 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002482
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002483 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002484 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002485 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2486#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2487#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2488#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2489#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2490 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2491
2492 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2493 case Type::Builtin:
2494 case Type::Complex:
2495 case Type::Vector:
2496 case Type::ExtVector:
2497 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2498 case Type::ObjCObject:
2499 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2500 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2501 case Type::Record:
2502 case Type::Enum:
2503 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2504 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2505 case Type::TypeOf:
2506 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002507 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002508 case Type::DependentName:
2509 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2510 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2511 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2512 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2513 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002514 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002515 case Type::PackExpansion:
2516 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2517
2518 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2519 // further decay.
2520 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2521 case Type::FunctionProto:
2522 case Type::BlockPointer:
2523 case Type::MemberPointer:
2524 return type;
2525
2526 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2527 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2528 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2529 // optimizations available here.
2530 case Type::Pointer:
2531 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2532 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2533 break;
2534
2535 case Type::LValueReference: {
2536 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2537 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2538 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2539 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2540 break;
2541 }
2542
2543 case Type::RValueReference: {
2544 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2545 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2546 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2547 break;
2548 }
2549
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002550 case Type::Atomic: {
2551 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2552 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2553 break;
2554 }
2555
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002556 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2557 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2558 result = getConstantArrayType(
2559 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2560 cat->getSize(),
2561 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2562 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2563 break;
2564 }
2565
2566 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2567 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2568 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2569 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2570 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2571 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2572 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2573 dat->getBracketsRange());
2574 break;
2575 }
2576
2577 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2578 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2579 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2580 result = getVariableArrayType(
2581 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002582 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002583 ArrayType::Normal,
2584 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2585 SourceRange());
2586 break;
2587 }
2588
2589 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2590 case Type::VariableArray: {
2591 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2592 result = getVariableArrayType(
2593 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002594 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002595 ArrayType::Star,
2596 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2597 vat->getBracketsRange());
2598 break;
2599 }
2600 }
2601
2602 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002603 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002604}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002605
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002606/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2607/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002608QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2609 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002610 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002611 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002612 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002613 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2614 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002615 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002616
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002617 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2618 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2619 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002620 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002621 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002622 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002623 }
2624
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002625 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002626 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002627
2628 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2629 Types.push_back(New);
2630 return QualType(New, 0);
2631}
2632
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002633/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2634/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002635/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002636QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2637 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002638 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002639 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2640 SourceRange brackets) const {
2641 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2642 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002643 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2644
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002645 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2646 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2647 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2648 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2649 if (!numElements) {
2650 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2651 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2652 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2653 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2654 brackets);
2655 Types.push_back(newType);
2656 return QualType(newType, 0);
2657 }
2658
2659 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2660 // also build a canonical type.
2661
2662 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2663
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002664 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002665 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002666 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002667 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002668 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002669
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002670 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2671 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2672 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002673
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002674 // If we don't have one, build one.
2675 if (!canonTy) {
2676 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002677 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002678 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2679 brackets);
2680 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2681 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002682 }
2683
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002684 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2685 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002686 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002687
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002688 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2689 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002690 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002691 return canon;
2692
2693 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2694 // of the element type.
2695 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2696 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2697 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2698 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2699 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2700 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002701}
2702
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002703QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002704 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002705 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002706 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002707 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002708
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002709 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002710 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2711 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2712 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002713
2714 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002715 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2716 // qualifiers off the element type.
2717 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002718
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002719 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2720 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002721 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002722 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002723 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002724
2725 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002726 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2727 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2728 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002729 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002730
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002731 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2732 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002733
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002734 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2735 Types.push_back(newType);
2736 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002737}
2738
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002739/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2740/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002741QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002742 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002743 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002744
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002745 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2746 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002747 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002748
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002749 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002750 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2751 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2752
2753 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2754 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2755 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002756 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002757 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002758
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002759 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2760 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002761 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002762 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002763 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002764 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002765 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2766 Types.push_back(New);
2767 return QualType(New, 0);
2768}
2769
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002770/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002771/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002772QualType
2773ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002774 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002775
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002776 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2777 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002778 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002779 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002780 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002781 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2782 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2783
2784 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2785 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2786 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002787 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002788 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002789
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002790 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2791 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002792 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002793 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002794 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2795 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002796 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2797 Types.push_back(New);
2798 return QualType(New, 0);
2799}
2800
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002801QualType
2802ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2803 Expr *SizeExpr,
2804 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002805 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002806 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002807 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002808
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002809 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002810 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2811 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2812 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2813 if (Canon) {
2814 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2815 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002816 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2817 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2818 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002819 } else {
2820 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2821 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002822 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2823 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2824 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002825
2826 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2827 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2828 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2829 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002830 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2831 } else {
2832 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2833 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002834 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2835 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002836 }
2837 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002838
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002839 Types.push_back(New);
2840 return QualType(New, 0);
2841}
2842
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002843/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002844///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002845QualType
2846ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2847 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002848 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2849
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002850 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2851 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002852 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002853 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002854
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002855 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002856 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002857 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002858 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002859
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002860 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002861 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2862 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002863
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002864 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002865 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2866 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002867 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002868 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002869
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002870 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002871 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002872 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002873 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002874 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002875 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002876}
2877
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002878/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2879static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2880 return T.isCanonical() &&
2881 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2882 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2883}
2884
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002885QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002886ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002887 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002888 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2889
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002890 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2891 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002892 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002893 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2894 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002895
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002896 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002897 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002898 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002899 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002900
2901 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002902 bool isCanonical =
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002903 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002904 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002905 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002906 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002907 isCanonical = false;
2908
2909 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002910 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002911 QualType Canonical;
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00002912 if (!isCanonical) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002913 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002914 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2915 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002916 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002917
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002918 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002919 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002920 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002921
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002922 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2923 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2924 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2925 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2926 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2927 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2928 }
2929
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002930 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002931
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002932 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002933 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2934 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002935 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002936 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002937
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002938 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2939 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2940 // - parameter types
2941 // - exception types
2942 // - consumed-arguments flags
2943 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002944 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2945 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002946 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002947 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002948 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
2949 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
2950 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002951 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002952 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002953 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00002954 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002955 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002956 }
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00002957 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002958 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2959
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002960 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002961 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002962 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002963 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002964 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002965 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002966}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002967
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002968#ifndef NDEBUG
2969static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2970 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2971 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2972 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2973 return true;
2974 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2975 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2976 return true;
2977 return false;
2978}
2979#endif
2980
2981/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2982/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2983QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002984 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002985 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2986 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2987 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002988 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002989 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2990 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2991 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2992 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002993 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002994 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002995 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2996 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002997 }
2998 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2999}
3000
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003001/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3002/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003003QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003004 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003005 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003006
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003007 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003008 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003009
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003010 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3011 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3012
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003013 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003014 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003015 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003016 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003017 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003018 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003019 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003020 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003021 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003022 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3023 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3024 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003025 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003026 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003027
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003028 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003029}
3030
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003031/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003032/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003033QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003034ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3035 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003036 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003037
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003038 if (Canonical.isNull())
3039 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003040 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003041 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003042 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3043 Types.push_back(newType);
3044 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003045}
3046
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003047QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003048 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3049
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003050 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003051 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3052 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3053
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003054 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3055 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3056 Types.push_back(newType);
3057 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003058}
3059
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003060QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003061 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3062
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003063 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003064 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3065 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3066
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003067 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3068 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3069 Types.push_back(newType);
3070 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003071}
3072
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003073QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3074 QualType modifiedType,
3075 QualType equivalentType) {
3076 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3077 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3078
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003079 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003080 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3081 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3082
3083 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3084 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3085 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3086
3087 Types.push_back(type);
3088 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3089
3090 return QualType(type, 0);
3091}
3092
3093
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003094/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3095QualType
3096ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003097 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003098 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003099 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3100
3101 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3102 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003103 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003104 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3105 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3106
3107 if (!SubstParm) {
3108 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3109 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3110 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3111 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3112 }
3113
3114 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3115}
3116
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003117/// \brief Retrieve a
3118QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3119 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3120 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3121#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003122 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3123 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3124 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003125 }
3126#endif
3127
3128 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3129 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003130 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003131 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3132 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3133 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3134
3135 QualType Canon;
3136 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3137 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3138 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3139 ArgPack);
3140 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3141 }
3142
3143 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3144 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3145 ArgPack);
3146 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3147 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3148 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3149}
3150
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003151/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003152/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003153/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003154QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003155 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003156 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003157 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003158 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003159 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003160 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003161 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3162
3163 if (TypeParm)
3164 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003165
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003166 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003167 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003168 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003169
3170 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3171 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3172 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3173 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003174 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003175 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3176 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003177
3178 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3179 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3180
3181 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3182}
3183
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003184TypeSourceInfo *
3185ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3186 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3187 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003188 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003189 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3190 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003191 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003192
3193 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003194 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3195 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003196 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003197 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3198 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3199 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3200 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3201 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3202 return DI;
3203}
3204
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003205QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003206ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003207 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003208 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003209 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3210 "No dependent template names here!");
3211
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003212 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3213
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003214 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003215 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3216 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3217 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3218
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003219 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003220 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003221}
3222
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003223#ifndef NDEBUG
3224static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3225 unsigned NumArgs) {
3226 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3227 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3228 return true;
3229
3230 return true;
3231}
3232#endif
3233
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003234QualType
3235ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003236 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3237 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003238 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003239 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3240 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003241 // Look through qualified template names.
3242 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3243 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003244
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003245 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003246 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3247 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003248 QualType CanonType;
3249 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3250 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3251 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003252 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3253 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3254 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3255 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3256 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003257 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3258 NumArgs);
3259 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003260
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003261 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3262 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3263 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003264 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3265 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003266 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003267 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003268 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003269 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3270 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003271
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003272 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003274}
3275
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003276QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003277ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3278 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003279 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003280 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3281 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003282
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003283 // Look through qualified template names.
3284 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3285 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003286
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003287 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3288 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003289 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003290 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3291 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3292 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3293
3294 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3295 // exists.
3296 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3297 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3298 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3299
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003300 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003301 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3302 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3303
3304 if (!Spec) {
3305 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3306 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3307 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3308 TypeAlignment);
3309 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3310 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003311 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003312 Types.push_back(Spec);
3313 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3314 }
3315
3316 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3317 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3318 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3319}
3320
3321QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003322ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3323 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003324 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003325 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003326 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003327
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003328 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003329 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003330 if (T)
3331 return QualType(T, 0);
3332
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003333 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3334 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3335 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003336 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3337 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003338 (void)CheckT;
3339 }
3340
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003341 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003342 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003343 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003344 return QualType(T, 0);
3345}
3346
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003347QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003348ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003349 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3350 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3351
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003352 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003353 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3354 if (T)
3355 return QualType(T, 0);
3356
3357 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3358 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3359 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3360 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3361 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3362 (void)CheckT;
3363 }
3364
3365 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3366 Types.push_back(T);
3367 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3368 return QualType(T, 0);
3369}
3370
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003371QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3372 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3373 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003374 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003375 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3376 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003377 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3378 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3379 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3380
3381 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3382 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003383 }
3384
3385 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003386 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003387
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003388 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003389 DependentNameType *T
3390 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003391 if (T)
3392 return QualType(T, 0);
3393
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003394 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003395 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003396 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003397 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003398}
3399
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003400QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003401ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3402 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003403 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003404 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003405 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003406 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003407 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003408 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3409 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3410 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3411 ArgCopy.size(),
3412 ArgCopy.data());
3413}
3414
3415QualType
3416ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3417 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3418 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3419 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3420 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003421 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003422 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3423 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003424
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003425 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003426 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3427 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003428
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003429 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003430 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3431 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003432 if (T)
3433 return QualType(T, 0);
3434
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003435 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003436
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003437 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3438 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3439
3440 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003441 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003442 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3443 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3444 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3445 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003446 }
3447
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003448 QualType Canon;
3449 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3450 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3451 Name, NumArgs,
3452 CanonArgs.data());
3453
3454 // Find the insert position again.
3455 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3456 }
3457
3458 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3459 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3460 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003461 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003462 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003463 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003464 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003465 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003466}
3467
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003468QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003469 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003470 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003471 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003472
3473 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3474 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003475 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003476 PackExpansionType *T
3477 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3478 if (T)
3479 return QualType(T, 0);
3480
3481 QualType Canon;
3482 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003483 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3484 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3485 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3486 // parameters.
3487 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003488 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003489
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003490 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3491 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3492 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3493 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003494 }
3495
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003496 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003497 Types.push_back(T);
3498 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003499 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003500}
3501
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003502/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3503/// alphabetically.
3504static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3505 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003506 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003507}
3508
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003509static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003510 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3511 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3512
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003513 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3514 return false;
3515
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003516 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003517 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3518 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003519 return false;
3520 return true;
3521}
3522
3523static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003524 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3525 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003526
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003527 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3528 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3529
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003530 // Canonicalize.
3531 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3532 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3533
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003534 // Remove duplicates.
3535 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3536 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3537}
3538
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003539QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3540 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003541 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003542 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3543 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3544 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3545 return BaseType;
3546
3547 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003548 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003549 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003550 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003551 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3552 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003553
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003554 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3555 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003556 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003557 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3558 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3559 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003560 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003561 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003562 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3563
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003564 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003565 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3566 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003567 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003568 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3569 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003570 }
3571
3572 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003573 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3574 }
3575
3576 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3577 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3578 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3579 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3580 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3581
3582 Types.push_back(T);
3583 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3584 return QualType(T, 0);
3585}
3586
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003587/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3588/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3589/// list.
3590bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3591 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3592 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3593 return false;
3594
3595 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3596 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003597 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003598 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3599 return false;
3600 }
3601 return true;
3602 }
3603 return false;
3604}
3605
3606/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3607/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3608/// of protocols.
3609bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3610 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3611 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3612 return false;
3613 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3614 if (!OPT)
3615 return false;
3616 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3617 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003618 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3619 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3620 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3621 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003622 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3623 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3624 bool Conforms = false;
3625 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3626 Conforms = false;
3627 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3628 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3629 Conforms = true;
3630 break;
3631 }
3632 }
3633 if (!Conforms)
3634 break;
3635 }
3636 if (Conforms)
3637 return true;
3638
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003639 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003640 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3641 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003642 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00003643 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00003644 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003645 break;
3646 }
3647 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00003648 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00003649 }
3650 return true;
3651}
3652
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003653/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3654/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003655QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003656 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3657 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3658
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003659 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003660 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3661 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3662 return QualType(QT, 0);
3663
3664 // Find the canonical object type.
3665 QualType Canonical;
3666 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3667 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3668
3669 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003670 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3671 }
3672
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003673 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003674 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3675 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3676 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003677
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003678 Types.push_back(QType);
3679 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003680 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003681}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003682
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003683/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3684/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003685QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3686 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003687 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3688 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003689
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003690 if (PrevDecl) {
3691 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3692 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3693 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3694 }
3695
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003696 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3697 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3698 Decl = Def;
3699
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003700 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3701 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3702 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3703 Types.push_back(T);
3704 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003705}
3706
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003707/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3708/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003709/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003710/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003711/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003712QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003713 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003714 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3715 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3716 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003717
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003718 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003719 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3720 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3721 if (Canon) {
3722 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3723 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003724 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003725 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003726 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003727 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003728 Canon
3729 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003730 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3731 toe = Canon;
3732 }
3733 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003734 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003735 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003736 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003737 Types.push_back(toe);
3738 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003739}
3740
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003741/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003742/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003743/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003744/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3745/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003746QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003747 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003748 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003749 Types.push_back(tot);
3750 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003751}
3752
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003753
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003754/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3755/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3756/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3757/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003758QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003759 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003760
3761 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003762 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003763 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3764 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003765 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003766 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3767 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003768
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003769 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003770 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3771 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003772 if (!Canon) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003773 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003774 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003775 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003776 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003777 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3778 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003779 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00003780 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3781 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003782 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003783 Types.push_back(dt);
3784 return QualType(dt, 0);
3785}
3786
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003787/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3788/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3789QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3790 QualType UnderlyingType,
3791 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3792 const {
3793 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003794 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3795 Kind,
3796 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003797 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003798 Types.push_back(Ty);
3799 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3800}
3801
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003802/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3803/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3804/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3805QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003806 bool IsDependent) const {
3807 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003808 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003809
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003810 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003811 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003812 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003813 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003814 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3815 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003816
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003817 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003818 IsDecltypeAuto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003819 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003820 Types.push_back(AT);
3821 if (InsertPos)
3822 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3823 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003824}
3825
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003826/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3827/// the given value type.
3828QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3829 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3830 // structure.
3831 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3832 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3833
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003834 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003835 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3836 return QualType(AT, 0);
3837
3838 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3839 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3840 QualType Canonical;
3841 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3842 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3843
3844 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3845 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003846 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003847 }
3848 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3849 Types.push_back(New);
3850 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3851 return QualType(New, 0);
3852}
3853
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003854/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3855QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3856 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003857 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3858 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00003859 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003860 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003861 return AutoDeductTy;
3862}
3863
3864/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3865QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3866 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3867 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3868 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3869 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3870}
3871
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003872/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3873/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003874QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003875 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003876 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3877 // away const? mutable?
3878 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003879}
3880
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003881/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3882/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3883/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003884CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003885 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003886}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003887
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003888/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3889CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3890 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3891}
3892
3893/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3894CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3895 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3896}
3897
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003898/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3899/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3900QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3901 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3902 return WCharTy;
3903}
3904
3905/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3906/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3907QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3908 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3909 return UnsignedIntTy;
3910}
3911
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003912QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3913 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3914}
3915
3916QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3917 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3918}
3919
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003920/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003921/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3922QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003923 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003924}
3925
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003926/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3927/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3928QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3929 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3930}
3931
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003932//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3933// Type Operators
3934//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3935
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003936CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003937 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3938 // qualifiers.
3939 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003940 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003941 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003942 QualType Result;
3943 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3944 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3945 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3946 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3947 } else {
3948 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3949 }
3950
3951 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3952}
3953
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003954QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3955 Qualifiers &quals) {
3956 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3957
3958 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3959 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3960 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3961 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3962 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003963 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003964
3965 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003966 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003967 quals = splitType.Quals;
3968 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003969 }
3970
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003971 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3972 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3973 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3974
3975 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3976 // can just use the results in splitType.
3977 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3978 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003979 quals = splitType.Quals;
3980 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003981 }
3982
3983 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3984 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003985 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003986
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003987 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003988 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003989 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3990 }
3991
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003992 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003993 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003994 }
3995
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003996 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003997 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003998 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003999 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4000 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4001 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4002 }
4003
4004 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004005 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004006 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4007 SourceRange());
4008}
4009
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004010/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4011/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4012/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4013/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4014/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4015/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4016/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4017/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4018bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4019 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4020 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4021 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4022 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4023 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4024 return true;
4025 }
4026
4027 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4028 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4029 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4030 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4031 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4032 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4033 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4034 return true;
4035 }
4036
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004037 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004038 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4039 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4040 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4041 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4042 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4043 return true;
4044 }
4045 }
4046
4047 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4048
4049 return false;
4050}
4051
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004052DeclarationNameInfo
4053ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4054 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004055 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4056 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4057 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004058 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004059 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4060 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004061
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004062 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4063 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4064 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4065 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4066 }
4067
4068 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4069 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004070 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004071 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004072 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4073 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004074 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004075 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4076 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4077 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4078 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4079 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4080 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004081 }
4082 }
4083
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004084 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4085 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4086 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4087 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4088 NameLoc);
4089 }
4090
4091 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4092 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4093 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4094 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4095 NameLoc);
4096 }
4097 }
4098
4099 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004100}
4101
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004102TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004103 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4104 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4105 case TemplateName::Template: {
4106 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004107 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004108 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004109 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4110
4111 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004112 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004113 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004114
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004115 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4116 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004117
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004118 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4119 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4120 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4121 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4122 }
4123
4124 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4125 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4126 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4127 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4128 }
4129
4130 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4131 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4132 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4133 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4134 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4135 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4136 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4137 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4138 }
4139 }
4140
4141 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004142}
4143
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004144bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4145 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4146 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4147 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4148}
4149
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004150TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004151ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004152 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4153 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4154 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004155
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004156 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004157 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004158
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004159 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004160 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004161 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004162 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004163
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004164 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4165 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4166 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4167
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004168 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4169 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004170
4171 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4172 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4173 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004174 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004175
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004176 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004177 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004178
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004179 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004180 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004181
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004182 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004183 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4184 return Arg;
4185
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004186 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4187 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004188 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004189 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004190 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4191 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4192 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004193
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004194 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004195 }
4196 }
4197
4198 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004199 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004200}
4201
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004202NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004203ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004204 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004205 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004206
4207 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4208 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4209 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004210 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004211 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4212 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4213
4214 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4215 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4216 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004217 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004218 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4219
4220 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4221 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4222 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004223 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004224 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4225 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004226
4227 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4228 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4229 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004230
4231 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4232 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4233 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4234 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4235 // types, e.g.,
4236 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4237 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004238 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4239 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004240 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004241
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004242 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4243 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4244 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004245 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4246 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004247 }
4248
4249 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004250 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4251 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004252 return NNS;
4253 }
4254
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004255 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004256}
4257
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004258
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004259const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004260 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004261 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004262 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4263 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4264 return AT;
4265 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004266
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004267 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004268 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004269 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004270
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004271 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004272 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4273 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004274
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004275 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4276 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004277 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004278
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004279 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004280 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004281
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004282 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004283 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004284 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004285 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004286
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004287 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4288 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004289 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004290
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004291 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4292 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4293 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004294 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004295 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4296 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4297 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004298 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004299
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004300 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004301 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4302 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004303 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004304 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004305 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004306 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004307 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004308
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004309 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004310 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004311 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004312 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004313 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004314 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004315}
4316
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004317QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004318 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4319 return getDecayedType(T);
4320 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004321}
4322
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004323QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004324 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4325 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4326 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4327}
4328
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004329/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4330/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4331/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4332/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4333///
4334/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004335QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004336 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4337 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4338 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4339 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4340 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4341 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004342
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004343 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004344
4345 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004346 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004347}
4348
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004349QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4350 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004351}
4352
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004353QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4354 Qualifiers qs;
4355 while (true) {
4356 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004357 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004358 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004359
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004360 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004361 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004362 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004363
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004364 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004365}
4366
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004367/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004368uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004369ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4370 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4371 do {
4372 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004373 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4374 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004375 } while (CA);
4376 return ElementCount;
4377}
4378
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004379/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4380/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004381static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004382 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004383 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004384
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004385 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4386 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004387 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004388 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004389 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4390 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4391 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004392 }
4393}
4394
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004395/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4396/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004397/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4398/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004399QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4400 QualType Domain) const {
4401 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4402 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4403 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004404 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004405 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4406 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4407 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4408 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004409 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004410
4411 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4412 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004413 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004414 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4415 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4416 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004417 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004418 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004419}
4420
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004421/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4422/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4423/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004424/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004425int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004426 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4427 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004428
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004429 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004430 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004431 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004432 return 1;
4433 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004434}
4435
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004436/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4437/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4438/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004439unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004440 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004441
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004442 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004443 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004444 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004445 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004446 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4447 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4448 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4449 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004450 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004451 case BuiltinType::Short:
4452 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004453 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004454 case BuiltinType::Int:
4455 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004456 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004457 case BuiltinType::Long:
4458 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004459 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004460 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4461 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004462 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004463 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4464 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4465 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004466 }
4467}
4468
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004469/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4470/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4471///
4472/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4473/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004474QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004475 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4476 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004477
4478 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4479 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4480 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4481
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004482 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004483 if (!Field)
4484 return QualType();
4485
4486 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4487
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004488 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004489 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004490 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4491 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4492 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4493 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4494 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4495 // promotion applies to it.
4496 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4497 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4498 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4499 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4500 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
4501 //
4502 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4503 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004504 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4505 return IntTy;
4506
4507 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4508 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4509
4510 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00004511 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4512 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4513 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4514 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004515 return QualType();
4516}
4517
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004518/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4519/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4520/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004521QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004522 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4523 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004524 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4525 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004526
4527 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4528 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4529 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4530 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4531 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4532 // unsigned long long int [...]
4533 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4534 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4535 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4536 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4537 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4538 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4539 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4540 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4541 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4542 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4543 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4544 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4545 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4546 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4547 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4548 }
4549 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4550 }
4551 }
4552
4553 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004554 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4555 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004556 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4557 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004558 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4559 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4560}
4561
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004562/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4563/// type and returns its ownership.
4564Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4565 while (!T.isNull()) {
4566 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4567 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4568 if (T->isArrayType())
4569 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4570 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4571 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4572 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004573 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004574 else
4575 break;
4576 }
4577
4578 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4579}
4580
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004581static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4582 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4583 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4584 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4585 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004586 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004587}
4588
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004589/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004590/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004591/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004592int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004593 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4594 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00004595
4596 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4597 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4598 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4599 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4600 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4601
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004602 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004603
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004604 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4605 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004606
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004607 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4608 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004609
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004610 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4611 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4612 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4613 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004614
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004615 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4616 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4617 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4618 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4619 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004620
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004621 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4622 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004623 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004624 return -1;
4625 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004626
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004627 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4628 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4629 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004630
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004631 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4632 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004633 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004634 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004635}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004636
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004637// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004638QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004639 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004640 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004641 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004642
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004643 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004644
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004645 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004646 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004647 // int flags;
4648 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004649 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004650 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004651 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004652 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4653
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004654 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004655 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004656 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004657 SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004658 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4659 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4660 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004661 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004662 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004663 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004664 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004665 }
4666
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004667 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004668 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004669
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004670 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004671}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004672
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004673QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4674 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004675 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004676 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4677 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4678 }
4679 return ObjCSuperType;
4680}
4681
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004682void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004683 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004684 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4685 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4686}
4687
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004688QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004689 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4690 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4691
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004692 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004693 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004694 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4695 RD->startDefinition();
4696
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004697 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4698 UnsignedLongTy,
4699 UnsignedLongTy,
4700 };
4701
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004702 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004703 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004704 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004705 };
4706
4707 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004708 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4709 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004710 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4711 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004712 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004713 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004714 }
4715
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004716 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004717
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004718 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004719
4720 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4721}
4722
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004723QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004724 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4725 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4726
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004727 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004728 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004729 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4730 RD->startDefinition();
4731
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004732 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4733 UnsignedLongTy,
4734 UnsignedLongTy,
4735 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4736 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4737 };
4738
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00004739 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004740 "reserved",
4741 "Size",
4742 "CopyFuncPtr",
4743 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4744 };
4745
4746 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004747 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4748 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004749 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4750 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004751 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004752 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004753 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004754 }
4755
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004756 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004757
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00004758 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004759 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4760}
4761
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004762/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4763/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4764/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4765bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4766 const VarDecl *D) {
4767 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4768 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4769 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4770
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004771 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004772 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004773
4774 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4775
4776 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4777
4778 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4779 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4780 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4781
4782 switch (lifetime) {
4783 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4784
4785 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4786 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4787 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4788 return false;
4789
4790 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4791 // byref routines.
4792 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4793 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4794 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4795 return true;
4796 }
4797 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4798 }
4799 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4800 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004801}
4802
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004803bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4804 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4805 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4806
4807 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4808 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4809 return false;
4810
4811 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004812 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004813 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4814 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4815 }
4816 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4817 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4818 // MRR.
4819 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4820 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4821 else
4822 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4823 return true;
4824}
4825
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004826TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4827 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00004828 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4829 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004830 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4831}
4832
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004833// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4834// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004835static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004836 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004837 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4838 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004840 return false;
4841}
4842
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004843/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004844/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004845CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004846 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4847 return CharUnits::Zero();
4848
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004849 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004850
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004851 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004852 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004853 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004854 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4855 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004856 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004857 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004858}
4859
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00004860bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
4861 return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
4862 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
4863 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
4864}
4865
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004866static inline
4867std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4868 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004869}
4870
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004871/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004872/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004873std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4874 std::string S;
4875
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004876 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4877 QualType BlockTy =
4878 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4879 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004880 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004881 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4882 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4883 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004884 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004885 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004886 // Compute size of all parameters.
4887 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4888 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4889 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004890 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4891 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004892 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4893 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004894 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004895 if (sz.isZero())
4896 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004897 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004898 ParmOffset += sz;
4899 }
4900 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004901 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004902 // Block pointer and offset.
4903 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004904
4905 // Argument types.
4906 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00004907 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004908 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4909 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4910 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4911 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4912 // elements.
4913 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4914 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4915 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4916 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004917 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004918 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4919 S, true /*Extended*/);
4920 else
4921 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004922 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004923 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004924 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004925
4926 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004927}
4928
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004929bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004930 std::string& S) {
4931 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004932 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004933 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4934 // Compute size of all parameters.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004935 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4936 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004937 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004938 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004939 continue;
4940
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004941 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004942 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004943 ParmOffset += sz;
4944 }
4945 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4946 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4947
4948 // Argument types.
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00004949 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004950 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4951 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4952 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4953 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4954 // elements.
4955 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4956 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4957 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4958 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4959 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4960 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4961 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4962 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004963
4964 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004965}
4966
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004967/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4968/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4969/// block object types.
4970void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4971 QualType T, std::string& S,
4972 bool Extended) const {
4973 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4974 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4975 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004976 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004977 true /*OutermostType*/,
4978 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4979 false /*StructField*/,
4980 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4981 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4982}
4983
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004984/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004985/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004986bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004987 std::string& S,
4988 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004989 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004990 // Encode return type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00004991 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4992 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004993 // Compute size of all parameters.
4994 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4995 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4996 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004997 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004998 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4999 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005000 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005001 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005002 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005003 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005004 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005005 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005006 continue;
5007
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005008 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5009 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005010 ParmOffset += sz;
5011 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005012 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005013 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005014 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005015
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005016 // Argument types.
5017 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005018 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005019 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005020 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005021 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005022 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005023 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5024 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5025 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005026 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005027 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5028 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5029 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005030 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5031 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005032 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005033 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005034 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005035
5036 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005037}
5038
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005039ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5040ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5041 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5042 const Decl *Container) const {
5043 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005044 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005045 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5046 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005047 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5048 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5049 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005050 } else {
5051 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5052 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5053 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5054 return PID;
5055 }
5056 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005057}
5058
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005059/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005060/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005061/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5062/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005063/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5064/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5065/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5066/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5067/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005068/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5069/// @code
5070/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5071/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5072/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5073/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5074/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5075/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5076/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5077/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005078/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005079/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5080/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5081/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5082/// };
5083/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005084void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005085 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005086 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005087 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5088 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005089 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005090
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005091 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5092 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5093 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5094 Dynamic = true;
5095 else
5096 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005097 }
5098
5099 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5100 S = "T";
5101
5102 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005103 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5104 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005105 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005106
5107 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5108 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005109 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5110 S += ",C";
5111 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5112 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005113 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5114 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005115 } else {
5116 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5117 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5118 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005119 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005120 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005121 }
5122 }
5123
5124 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5125 // are "dynamic by default".
5126 if (Dynamic)
5127 S += ",D";
5128
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005129 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5130 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005131
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005132 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5133 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005134 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005135 }
5136
5137 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5138 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005139 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005140 }
5141
5142 if (SynthesizePID) {
5143 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5144 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005145 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005146 }
5147
5148 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5149}
5150
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005151/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5153/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005154/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5155///
5156void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005157 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005158 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005159 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005160 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005161 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005162 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005163 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5164 }
5165 }
5166}
5167
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005168void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005169 const FieldDecl *Field,
5170 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005171 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5172 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5173 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5174 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005175 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005176 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5177 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005178}
5179
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005180void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5181 std::string& S) const {
5182 // Encode result type.
5183 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5184 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5185 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5186 true /* outermost type */,
5187 true /* encoding property */);
5188}
5189
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005190static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5191 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5192 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005193 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5194 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5195 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5196 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005197 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005198 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005199 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005200 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5201 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005202 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005203 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5204 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5205 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5206 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5207 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005208 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5209 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005210 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5211 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005212 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005213 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5214 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5215 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5216 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005217 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005218 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5219
5220 case BuiltinType::Half:
5221 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5222 return ' ';
5223
5224 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5225 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5226 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5227 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5228
5229 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5230 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5231 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5232 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5233 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5234 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5235 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005236 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005237 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005238 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5239#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5240#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5241 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5242#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5243 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005244 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005245 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005246}
5247
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005248static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5249 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5250
5251 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5252 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5253 return 'i';
5254
5255 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005256 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5257 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005258}
5259
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005260static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005261 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005262 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005263 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005264 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5265 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5266 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5267 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5268 //
5269 // struct
5270 // {
5271 // int integer;
5272 // int flags:2;
5273 // };
5274 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5275 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5276 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5277 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5278 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005279 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005280 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5281 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005282 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005283 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5284 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005285 else {
5286 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5287 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5288 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005289 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005290 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005291}
5292
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005293// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005294void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5295 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5296 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005297 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005298 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005299 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005300 bool StructField,
5301 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005302 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005303 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5304 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005305 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5306 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5307 case Type::Builtin:
5308 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005309 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005310 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005311 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5312 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5313 else
5314 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005315 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005316
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005317 case Type::Complex: {
5318 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005319 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005320 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005321 return;
5322 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005323
5324 case Type::Atomic: {
5325 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5326 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005327 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005328 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005329 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005330
5331 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5332 case Type::Pointer:
5333 case Type::LValueReference:
5334 case Type::RValueReference: {
5335 QualType PointeeTy;
5336 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5337 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5338 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5339 S += ':';
5340 return;
5341 }
5342 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5343 } else {
5344 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5345 }
5346
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005347 bool isReadOnly = false;
5348 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5349 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5350 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005351 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005352 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005353 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5354 isReadOnly = true;
5355 S += 'r';
5356 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005357 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005358 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005359 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5360 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005361 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5362 isReadOnly = true;
5363 S += 'r';
5364 }
5365 }
5366 if (isReadOnly) {
5367 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5368 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5369 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005370 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005371 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005372 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005373
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005374 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5375 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5376 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005377 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005378 S += '*';
5379 return;
5380 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005381 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005382 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5383 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5384 S += '#';
5385 return;
5386 }
5387 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5388 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5389 S += '@';
5390 return;
5391 }
5392 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005393 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005394 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005395 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5396
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005397 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005398 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5399 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005400 return;
5401 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005402
5403 case Type::ConstantArray:
5404 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5405 case Type::VariableArray: {
5406 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5407
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005408 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005409 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5410 S += '^';
5411
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005412 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005413 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5414 } else {
5415 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005416
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00005417 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5418 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5419 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005420 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005421 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5422 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005423 S += '0';
5424 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005425
5426 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005427 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5428 false, false, false, false, false, false,
5429 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005430 S += ']';
5431 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005432 return;
5433 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005434
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005435 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5436 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005437 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005438 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005439
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005440 case Type::Record: {
5441 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005442 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005443 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5444 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5445 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005446 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5447 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5448 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005449 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5450 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005451 TemplateArgs.data(),
5452 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005453 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005454 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005455 } else {
5456 S += '?';
5457 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005458 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005459 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005460 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005461 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005462 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005463 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005464 if (FD) {
5465 S += '"';
5466 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5467 S += '"';
5468 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005469
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005470 // Special case bit-fields.
5471 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5472 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00005473 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005474 } else {
5475 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5476 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5477 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5478 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5479 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005480 /*StructField*/true,
5481 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005482 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005483 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005484 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005485 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005486 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005487 return;
5488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005490 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5491 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005492 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005493 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005494 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005495
5496 S += '<';
5497 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005498 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5499 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5500 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005501 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5502 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005503 // Block self
5504 S += "@?";
5505 // Block parameters
5506 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00005507 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5508 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5509 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5510 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005511 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5512 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005513 }
5514 S += '>';
5515 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005516 return;
5517 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005518
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00005519 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5520 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5521 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5522 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5523 S += "{objc_object=}";
5524 return;
5525 }
5526 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5527 S += "{objc_class=}";
5528 return;
5529 }
5530 }
5531
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005532 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5533 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5534 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005535
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005536 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5537 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5538 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005539 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005540 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005541 S += '{';
5542 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5543 S += II->getName();
5544 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005545 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005546 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5547 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005548 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005549 if (Field->isBitField())
5550 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005551 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005552 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5553 false, false, false, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005554 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5555 NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005556 }
5557 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005558 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005559 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005560
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005561 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5562 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005563 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5564 S += '@';
5565 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005566 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005567
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005568 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5569 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5570 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5571 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005572 S += '#';
5573 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005574 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005575
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005576 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005577 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005578 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5579 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005580 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005581 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5582 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005583 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005584 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005585 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005586 S += I->getNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005587 S += '>';
5588 }
5589 S += '"';
5590 }
5591 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005592 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005593
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005594 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5595 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005596 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5597 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005598 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005599 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005600 // {...};
5601 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005602 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00005603 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00005604 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5605 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5606 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5607 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5608 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5609 S += '{';
5610 S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5611 S += '}';
5612 return;
5613 }
5614 }
5615 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005616 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5617 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005618 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005619 false, false, false, false, false,
5620 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005621 return;
5622 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005623
5624 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005625 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5626 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005627 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005628 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005629 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005630 S += '<';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00005631 S += I->getNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005632 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005633 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005634 S += '"';
5635 }
5636 return;
5637 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005638
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005639 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005640 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5641 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005642 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5643 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005644 case Type::Vector:
5645 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005646 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5647 { if (NotEncodedT)
5648 *NotEncodedT = T;
5649 return;
5650 }
5651
5652 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5653 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005654 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005655 return;
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005656
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005657
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005658#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5659#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5660#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5661 case Type::KIND:
5662#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5663 case Type::KIND:
5664#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5665 case Type::KIND:
5666#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5667 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005668 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005669 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005670}
5671
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005672void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5673 std::string &S,
5674 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005675 bool includeVBases,
5676 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005677 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5678 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5679 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5680 return;
5681
5682 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5683 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5684 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5685
5686 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00005687 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5688 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5689 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005690 if (base->isEmpty())
5691 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005692 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005693 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5694 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5695 }
5696 }
5697 }
5698
5699 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005700 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005701 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5702 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00005703 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5704 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005705 }
5706
5707 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00005708 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5709 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005710 if (base->isEmpty())
5711 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005712 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00005713 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5714 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005715 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5716 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005717 }
5718 }
5719
5720 CharUnits size;
5721 if (CXXRec) {
5722 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5723 } else {
5724 size = layout.getSize();
5725 }
5726
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005727#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005728 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005729#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005730 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5731 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5732
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005733 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5734 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005735 if (FD) {
5736 S += "\"_vptr$";
5737 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5738 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5739 S += recname;
5740 S += '"';
5741 }
5742 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005743#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005744 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005745#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005746 }
5747
5748 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5749 // Mark the end of the structure.
5750 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5751 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005752 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005753 }
5754
5755 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005756#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005757 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005758 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5759 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5760 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5761 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5762 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5763 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5764 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5765 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5766 // longer then though.
5767 CurOffs += padding;
5768 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005769#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005770
5771 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005772 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005773 break; // reached end of structure.
5774
5775 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5776 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5777 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5778 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5779 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005780 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
5781 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005782 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005783#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005784 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005785#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005786 } else {
5787 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5788 if (FD) {
5789 S += '"';
5790 S += field->getNameAsString();
5791 S += '"';
5792 }
5793
5794 if (field->isBitField()) {
5795 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005796#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005797 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005798#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005799 } else {
5800 QualType qt = field->getType();
5801 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5802 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5803 /*OutermostType*/false,
5804 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005805 /*StructField*/true,
5806 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005807#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005808 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00005809#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005810 }
5811 }
5812 }
5813}
5814
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005815void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005816 std::string& S) const {
5817 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5818 S += 'n';
5819 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5820 S += 'N';
5821 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5822 S += 'o';
5823 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5824 S += 'O';
5825 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5826 S += 'R';
5827 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5828 S += 'V';
5829}
5830
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005831TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5832 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005833 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005834 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005835 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005836 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005837 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005838}
5839
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005840TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5841 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005842 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5843 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005844 }
5845 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005846}
5847
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005848TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5849 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005850 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005851 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005852 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005853 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005854 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005855}
5856
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005857ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5858 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5859 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5860 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5861 SourceLocation(),
5862 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005863 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005864 SourceLocation(), true);
5865 }
5866
5867 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5868}
5869
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005870//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5871// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5872//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5873
5874static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5875 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005876 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5877 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005878}
5879
5880static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5881 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005882 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5883 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005884}
5885
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005886static TypedefDecl *
5887CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005888 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005889 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005890 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5891 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5892 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5893 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5894 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005895 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005896 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005897 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005898 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005899 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005900 }
5901
5902 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5903
5904 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5905 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5906 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5907
5908 // void *__stack;
5909 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5910 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5911
5912 // void *__gr_top;
5913 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5914 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5915
5916 // void *__vr_top;
5917 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5918 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5919
5920 // int __gr_offs;
5921 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5922 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5923
5924 // int __vr_offs;
5925 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5926 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5927
5928 // Create fields
5929 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5930 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5931 VaListTagDecl,
5932 SourceLocation(),
5933 SourceLocation(),
5934 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005935 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5936 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005937 /*Mutable=*/false,
5938 ICIS_NoInit);
5939 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5940 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5941 }
5942 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5943 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5944 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5945
5946 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005947 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005948}
5949
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005950static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5951 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5952 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5953
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005954 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005955 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5956
5957 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5958 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5959 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5960
5961 // unsigned char gpr;
5962 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5963 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5964
5965 // unsigned char fpr;
5966 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5967 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5968
5969 // unsigned short reserved;
5970 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5971 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5972
5973 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5974 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5975 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5976
5977 // void* reg_save_area;
5978 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5979 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5980
5981 // Create fields
5982 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5983 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5984 SourceLocation(),
5985 SourceLocation(),
5986 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005987 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5988 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005989 /*Mutable=*/false,
5990 ICIS_NoInit);
5991 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5992 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5993 }
5994 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5995 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005996 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005997
5998 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005999 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6000 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6001
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006002 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6003 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6004
6005 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6006 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6007 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6008 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6009 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006010 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006011}
6012
6013static TypedefDecl *
6014CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6015 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6016 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006017 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006018 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6019
6020 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6021 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6022 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6023
6024 // unsigned gp_offset;
6025 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6026 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6027
6028 // unsigned fp_offset;
6029 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6030 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6031
6032 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6033 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6034 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6035
6036 // void* reg_save_area;
6037 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6038 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6039
6040 // Create fields
6041 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6042 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6043 VaListTagDecl,
6044 SourceLocation(),
6045 SourceLocation(),
6046 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006047 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6048 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006049 /*Mutable=*/false,
6050 ICIS_NoInit);
6051 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6052 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6053 }
6054 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6055 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006056 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006057
6058 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006059 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6060 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6061
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006062 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6063 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6064
6065 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6066 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6067 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6068 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6069 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006070 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006071}
6072
6073static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6074 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6075 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6076 QualType IntArrayType
6077 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6078 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006079 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006080}
6081
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006082static TypedefDecl *
6083CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006084 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006085 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006086 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6087 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6088 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6089 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6090 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6091 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6092 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006093 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006094 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006095 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006096 }
6097
6098 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6099
6100 // void * __ap;
6101 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6102 VaListDecl,
6103 SourceLocation(),
6104 SourceLocation(),
6105 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6106 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006107 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6108 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006109 /*Mutable=*/false,
6110 ICIS_NoInit);
6111 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6112 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6113
6114 // };
6115 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6116
6117 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006118 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6119 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006120}
6121
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006122static TypedefDecl *
6123CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6124 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6125 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006126 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006127 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6128
6129 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6130 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6131 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6132
6133 // long __gpr;
6134 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6135 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6136
6137 // long __fpr;
6138 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6139 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6140
6141 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6142 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6143 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6144
6145 // void *__reg_save_area;
6146 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6147 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6148
6149 // Create fields
6150 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6151 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6152 VaListTagDecl,
6153 SourceLocation(),
6154 SourceLocation(),
6155 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006156 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6157 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006158 /*Mutable=*/false,
6159 ICIS_NoInit);
6160 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6161 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6162 }
6163 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6164 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6165 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6166
6167 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006168 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6169 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006170 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6171 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6172
6173 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6174 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6175 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6176 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6177 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006178
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006179 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006180}
6181
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006182static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6183 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6184 switch (Kind) {
6185 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6186 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6187 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6188 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006189 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6190 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006191 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6192 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6193 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6194 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6195 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6196 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006197 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6198 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006199 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6200 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006201 }
6202
6203 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6204}
6205
6206TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006207 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006208 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006209 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6210 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006211
6212 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6213}
6214
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006215QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6216 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6217 // declaration.
6218 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6219 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6220
6221 return VaListTagTy;
6222}
6223
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006224void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006225 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006226 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006227
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006228 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006229}
6230
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006231/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6232/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006233TemplateName
6234ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6235 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006236 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6237 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6238
6239 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6240 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6241 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6242
6243 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006244 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006245 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6246 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6247 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6248 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6249 *Storage++ = D;
6250 }
6251
6252 return TemplateName(OT);
6253}
6254
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006255/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6256/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006257TemplateName
6258ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6259 bool TemplateKeyword,
6260 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006261 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6262
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006263 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006264 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6265 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6266
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006267 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006268 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6269 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6270 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006271 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6272 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006273 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6274 }
6275
6276 return TemplateName(QTN);
6277}
6278
6279/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6280/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006281TemplateName
6282ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6283 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006284 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006285 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006286
6287 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6288 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6289
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006290 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006291 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6292 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6293
6294 if (QTN)
6295 return TemplateName(QTN);
6296
6297 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6298 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006299 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6300 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006301 } else {
6302 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006303 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6304 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006305 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6306 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6307 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6308 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006309 }
6310
6311 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6312 return TemplateName(QTN);
6313}
6314
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006315/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6316/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6317TemplateName
6318ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006319 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006320 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6321 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6322
6323 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6324 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006325
6326 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006327 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6328 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006329
6330 if (QTN)
6331 return TemplateName(QTN);
6332
6333 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6334 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006335 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6336 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006337 } else {
6338 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006339 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6340 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006341
6342 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6343 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6344 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6345 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006346 }
6347
6348 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6349 return TemplateName(QTN);
6350}
6351
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006352TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006353ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6354 TemplateName replacement) const {
6355 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6356 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006357
6358 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006359 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6360 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6361
6362 if (!subst) {
6363 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6364 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6365 }
6366
6367 return TemplateName(subst);
6368}
6369
6370TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006371ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6372 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6373 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6374 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6375 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006376
6377 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006378 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6379 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6380
6381 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006382 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006383 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6384 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6385 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6386 }
6387
6388 return TemplateName(Subst);
6389}
6390
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006391/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006392/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6393/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006394CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006395 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006396 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00006397 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6398 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006399 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6400 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6401 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6402 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6403 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6404 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6405 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6406 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6407 }
6408
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006409 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006410}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006411
6412//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6413// Type Predicates.
6414//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6415
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006416/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6417/// garbage collection attribute.
6418///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006419Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006420 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006421 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6422
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006423 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006424 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6425
6426 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6427 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6428 // as __strong.
6429 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6430 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6431 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6432 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6433 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6434 } else {
6435 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6436 // pointer.
6437#ifndef NDEBUG
6438 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6439 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6440 CT = AT->getElementType();
6441 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6442#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006443 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006444 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006445}
6446
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006447//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6448// Type Compatibility Testing
6449//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006450
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006451/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006452/// compatible.
6453static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6454 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006455 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006456 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006457 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006458}
6459
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006460bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6461 QualType SecondVec) {
6462 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6463 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6464
6465 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6466 return true;
6467
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006468 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6469 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006470 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6471 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006472 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006473 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006474 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6475 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6476 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6477 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006478 return true;
6479
6480 return false;
6481}
6482
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006483//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6484// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6485//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6486
6487/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6488/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006489bool
6490ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6491 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006492 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006493 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00006494 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6495 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006496 return true;
6497 return false;
6498}
6499
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006500/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6501/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006502bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6503 QualType rhs) {
6504 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6505 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6506 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6507
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006508 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006509 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006510 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006511 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6512 match = true;
6513 break;
6514 }
6515 }
6516 if (!match)
6517 return false;
6518 }
6519 return true;
6520}
6521
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006522/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6523/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6524bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6525 bool compare) {
6526 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006527 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006528 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6529 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006530 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006531 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6532 return true;
6533
6534 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006535 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006536
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006537 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006538
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006539 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006540 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006541 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6542 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006543 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006544 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6545 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6546 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006547 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006548 return false;
6549 }
6550 }
6551 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6552 return true;
6553 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006554 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006555 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006556 bool match = false;
6557
6558 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6559 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6560 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006561 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006562 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6563 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6564 match = true;
6565 break;
6566 }
6567 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006568 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006569 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6570 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006571 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006572 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6573 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6574 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006575 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006576 match = true;
6577 break;
6578 }
6579 }
6580 }
6581 if (!match)
6582 return false;
6583 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006584
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006585 return true;
6586 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006587
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006588 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6589 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6590
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006591 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006592 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006593 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006594 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006595 bool match = false;
6596
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006597 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006598 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6599 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006600 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6601 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006602 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006603 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6604 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6605 match = true;
6606 break;
6607 }
6608 }
6609 if (!match)
6610 return false;
6611 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006612
6613 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6614 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6615 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6616 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6617 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6618 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6619 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6620 // assume that it is mismatch.
6621 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6622 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006623 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006624 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006625 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006626 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6627 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6628 match = true;
6629 break;
6630 }
6631 }
6632 if (!match)
6633 return false;
6634 }
6635 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006636 return true;
6637 }
6638 return false;
6639}
6640
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006641/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006642/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6643/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6644///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006645bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6646 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006647 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6648 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6649
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006650 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006651 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6652 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006653 return true;
6654
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006655 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006656 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6657 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006658 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006659
6660 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6661 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6662 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6663
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006664 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6665 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006666 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006667
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006668 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006669}
6670
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006671/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006672/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006673/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6674/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6675/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6676bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6677 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006678 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6679 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006680 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006681 return true;
6682
6683 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6684 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6685 }
6686
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006687 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006688 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6689 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6690 false);
6691
6692 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6693 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6694 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6695 if (LHS != RHS) {
6696 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006697 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006698 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006699 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006700 }
6701 else
6702 return true;
6703 }
6704 return false;
6705}
6706
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006707/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6708/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6709/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6710/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6711static
6712void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6713 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6714 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006715 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006716
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006717 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6718 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6719 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6720 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006721
6722 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6723 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6724 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6725 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6726 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006727 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006728 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6729 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006730 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6731 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6732 }
6733
6734 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6735 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006736 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6737 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006738 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6739 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6740 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006741 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006742 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006743 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6744 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Craig Topperc6914d02014-08-25 04:15:02 +00006745 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *ProtDecl : RHSInheritedProtocols)
6746 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(ProtDecl))
6747 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(ProtDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006748 }
6749}
6750
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006751/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6752/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6753/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6754/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6755QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006756 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6757 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6758 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6759 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6760 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6761 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006762 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006763 return QualType();
6764
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006765 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006766 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006767 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006768 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006769 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6770
6771 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6772 if (!Protocols.empty())
6773 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6774 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6775 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006776 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006777 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006778
6779 return QualType();
6780}
6781
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006782bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6783 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6784 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6785 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6786
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006787 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6788 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006789 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006790 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006791
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006792 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6793 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006794 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006795 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006796
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00006797 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. But RHS may or may not.
6798 // More detailed analysis is required.
6799 // OK, if LHS is same or a superclass of RHS *and*
6800 // this LHS, or as RHS's super class is assignment compatible with LHS.
6801 bool IsSuperClass =
6802 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6803 if (IsSuperClass) {
6804 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6805 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6806 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6807 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6808 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
6809 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
6810 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
6811 // qualifiers.
6812 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
6813 SuperClassInheritedProtocols.insert(RHSPI->getCanonicalDecl());
6814 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
6815 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006816 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00006817
6818 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6819 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6820 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
6821 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6822 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6823 break;
6824 }
6825 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6826 return false;
6827 }
6828 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006829 }
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00006830 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006831}
6832
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006833bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6834 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006835 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6836 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006837
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006838 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006839 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006840
6841 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6842 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006843}
6844
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006845bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6846 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6847 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6848 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6849}
6850
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006851/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006852/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006853/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006854/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006855bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6856 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006857 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006858 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6859
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006860 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006861}
6862
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006863bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006864 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006865}
6866
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006867bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6868 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6869}
6870
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006871/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6872/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6873/// QualType()
6874QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6875 bool OfBlockPointer,
6876 bool Unqualified) {
6877 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6878 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6879 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006880 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6881 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006882 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6883 if (!MT.isNull())
6884 return MT;
6885 }
6886 }
6887 }
6888
6889 return QualType();
6890}
6891
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00006892/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6893/// parameter types
6894QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6895 bool OfBlockPointer,
6896 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006897 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6898 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6899 // type is compatible with a union member
6900 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6901 Unqualified);
6902 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6903 return lmerge;
6904
6905 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6906 Unqualified);
6907 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6908 return rmerge;
6909
6910 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6911}
6912
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006913QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006914 bool OfBlockPointer,
6915 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006916 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6917 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006918 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6919 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006920 bool allLTypes = true;
6921 bool allRTypes = true;
6922
6923 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006924 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006925 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006926 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6927 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006928 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6929 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6930 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006931 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006932 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006933 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006934 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006935 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006936 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006937
6938 if (Unqualified)
6939 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6940
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006941 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6942 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006943 if (Unqualified) {
6944 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6945 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6946 }
6947
6948 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006949 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006950 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006951 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006952
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006953 // FIXME: double check this
6954 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6955 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6956 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006957 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6958 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006959
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006960 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00006961 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006962 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006963
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006964 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006965 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6966 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006967 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6968 return QualType();
6969
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006970 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6971 return QualType();
6972
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006973 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6974 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006975
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006976 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6977 allLTypes = false;
6978 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6979 allRTypes = false;
6980
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006981 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006982
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006983 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006984 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6985 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00006986 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
6987 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006988 return QualType();
6989
6990 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6991 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6992 return QualType();
6993
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006994 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6995 return QualType();
6996
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006997 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6998 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6999 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007000
7001 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007002 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007003 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7004 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7005 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7006 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7007 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7008 if (paramType.isNull())
7009 return QualType();
7010
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007011 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007012 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7013
7014 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007015 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007016 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7017 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007018 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007019
7020 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007021 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007022 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007023 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007024 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007025
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007026 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7027 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007028
7029 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7030 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007031 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007032 }
7033
7034 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7035 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7036
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007037 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007038 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007039 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007040 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7041 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7042 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7043 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7044 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7045 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007046 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7047 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007048
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007049 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007050 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007051 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7052 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7053 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007054 return QualType();
7055 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007056
7057 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7058 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007059 return QualType();
7060 }
7061
7062 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7063 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007064
7065 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7066 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007067 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007068 }
7069
7070 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7071 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007072 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007073}
7074
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007075/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7076static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7077 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7078 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7079 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7080 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7081 // type.
7082 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7083 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7084 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7085 return other;
7086
7087 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7088 // integral type of the same size.
7089 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7090 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7091 return other;
7092
7093 return QualType();
7094}
7095
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007096QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007097 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007098 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007099 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7100 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7101 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007102 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7103 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007104 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7105 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007106
7107 if (Unqualified) {
7108 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7109 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7110 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007111
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007112 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7113 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7114
7115 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7116 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7117 return LHS;
7118
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007119 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007120 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7121 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007122 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7123 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7124 // mismatch.
7125 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007126 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7127 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007128 return QualType();
7129
7130 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7131 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7132 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7133 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7134 // qualified __strong.
7135 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7136 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7137 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7138
7139 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7140 return QualType();
7141
7142 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7143 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7144 }
7145 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7146 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7147 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007148 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007149 }
7150
7151 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007152
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007153 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7154 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007155
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007156 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7157 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7158 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7159 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007160
7161 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007162 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7163 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7164 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7165 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007166
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007167 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7168 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7169 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7170
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007171 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7172 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7173 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007174
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007175 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007176 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007177 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7178 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007179 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007180 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007181 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007182 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007183 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007184 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007185 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007186 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7187 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7188 return LHS;
7189 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7190 return RHS;
7191 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007192
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007193 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007194 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007195
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007196 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007197 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007198#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7199#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007200#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007201#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7202#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7203#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007204 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007205
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007206 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007207 case Type::LValueReference:
7208 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007209 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007210 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007211
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007212 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007213 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7214 case Type::VariableArray:
7215 case Type::FunctionProto:
7216 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007217 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007218
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007219 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007220 {
7221 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007222 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7223 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007224 if (Unqualified) {
7225 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7226 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7227 }
7228 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7229 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007230 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007231 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007232 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007233 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007234 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007235 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7236 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007237 case Type::BlockPointer:
7238 {
7239 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007240 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7241 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007242 if (Unqualified) {
7243 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7244 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7245 }
7246 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7247 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007248 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7249 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7250 return LHS;
7251 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7252 return RHS;
7253 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7254 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007255 case Type::Atomic:
7256 {
7257 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7258 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7259 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7260 if (Unqualified) {
7261 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7262 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7263 }
7264 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7265 Unqualified);
7266 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7267 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7268 return LHS;
7269 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7270 return RHS;
7271 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7272 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007273 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007274 {
7275 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7276 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7277 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7278 return QualType();
7279
7280 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7281 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007282 if (Unqualified) {
7283 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7284 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7285 }
7286
7287 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007288 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007289 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7290 return LHS;
7291 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7292 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007293 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7294 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7295 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7296 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007297 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7298 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007299 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7300 return LHS;
7301 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7302 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007303 if (LVAT) {
7304 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7305 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7306 // has to be different.
7307 return LHS;
7308 }
7309 if (RVAT) {
7310 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7311 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7312 // has to be different.
7313 return RHS;
7314 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007315 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7316 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007317 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7318 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007319 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007320 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007321 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007322 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007323 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007324 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007325 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007326 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007327 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007328 case Type::Complex:
7329 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7330 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007331 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007332 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007333 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7334 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007335 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007336 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007337 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7338 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007339 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7340 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007341 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7342 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7343 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007344 return LHS;
7345
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007346 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007347 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007348 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007349 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7350 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7351 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007352 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7353 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007354 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007355 return QualType();
7356 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007357 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7358 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007359 return LHS;
7360
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007361 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007362 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007363 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007364
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007365 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007366}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007367
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007368bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7369 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7370 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007371 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7372 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007373 return false;
7374 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7375 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7376 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7377 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Tokerb3fd5cf2014-01-21 00:32:38 +00007378 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007379 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7380 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007381 return false;
7382 }
7383 return true;
7384}
7385
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007386/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7387/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7388/// return types.
7389QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7390 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7391 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7392 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7393 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7394 return LHS;
7395 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7396 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7397 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007398 QualType OldReturnType =
7399 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007400 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007401 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007402 QualType ResReturnType =
7403 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7404 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7405 return QualType();
7406 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7407 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7408 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7409 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7410 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007411 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7412 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00007413 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007414 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007415 return ResultType;
7416 }
7417 }
7418 return QualType();
7419 }
7420
7421 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7422 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7423 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7424 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7425 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7426 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7427 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7428 return QualType();
7429
7430 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7431 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7432 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7433 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7434 // qualified __strong.
7435 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7436 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7437 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7438
7439 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7440 return QualType();
7441
7442 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7443 return LHS;
7444 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7445 return RHS;
7446 return QualType();
7447 }
7448
7449 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7450 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7451 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7452 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7453 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7454 return LHS;
7455 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7456 return RHS;
7457 }
7458 return QualType();
7459}
7460
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007461//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007462// Integer Predicates
7463//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007464
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007465unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00007466 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007467 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007468 if (T->isBooleanType())
7469 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007470 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007471 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7472}
7473
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007474QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007475 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007476
7477 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7478 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7479 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007480 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007481
7482 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7483 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007484 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007485
7486 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7487 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007488 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7489 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7490 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7491 return UnsignedCharTy;
7492 case BuiltinType::Short:
7493 return UnsignedShortTy;
7494 case BuiltinType::Int:
7495 return UnsignedIntTy;
7496 case BuiltinType::Long:
7497 return UnsignedLongTy;
7498 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7499 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007500 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7501 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007502 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007503 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007504 }
7505}
7506
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007507ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7508
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007509void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7510 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007511
7512//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7513// Builtin Type Computation
7514//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7515
7516/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007517/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7518/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7519/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7520/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007521///
7522/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7523/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007524static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007525 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007526 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007527 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007528 // Modifiers.
7529 int HowLong = 0;
7530 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007531 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007532
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007533 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007534 bool Done = false;
7535 while (!Done) {
7536 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007537 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007538 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007539 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007540 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007541 case 'S':
7542 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7543 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7544 Signed = true;
7545 break;
7546 case 'U':
7547 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00007548 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007549 Unsigned = true;
7550 break;
7551 case 'L':
7552 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7553 ++HowLong;
7554 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00007555 case 'W':
7556 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7557 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7558 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7559 default:
7560 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7561 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7562 HowLong = 1;
7563 break;
7564 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7565 HowLong = 2;
7566 break;
7567 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007568 }
7569 }
7570
7571 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007572
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007573 // Read the base type.
7574 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007575 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007576 case 'v':
7577 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7578 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7579 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7580 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007581 case 'h':
7582 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00007583 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00007584 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7585 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007586 case 'f':
7587 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7588 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7589 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7590 break;
7591 case 'd':
7592 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7593 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7594 if (HowLong)
7595 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7596 else
7597 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7598 break;
7599 case 's':
7600 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7601 if (Unsigned)
7602 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7603 else
7604 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7605 break;
7606 case 'i':
7607 if (HowLong == 3)
7608 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7609 else if (HowLong == 2)
7610 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7611 else if (HowLong == 1)
7612 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7613 else
7614 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7615 break;
7616 case 'c':
7617 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7618 if (Signed)
7619 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7620 else if (Unsigned)
7621 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7622 else
7623 Type = Context.CharTy;
7624 break;
7625 case 'b': // boolean
7626 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7627 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7628 break;
7629 case 'z': // size_t.
7630 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7631 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7632 break;
7633 case 'F':
7634 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7635 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007636 case 'G':
7637 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7638 break;
7639 case 'H':
7640 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7641 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007642 case 'M':
7643 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7644 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007645 case 'a':
7646 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7647 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7648 break;
7649 case 'A':
7650 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7651 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7652 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7653 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7654 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7655 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7656 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7657 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7658 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7659 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007660 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007661 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007662 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007663 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007664 break;
7665 case 'V': {
7666 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007667 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7668 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007669 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007670
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007671 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7672 RequiresICE, false);
7673 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007674
7675 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007676 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007677 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007678 break;
7679 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007680 case 'E': {
7681 char *End;
7682
7683 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7684 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7685
7686 Str = End;
7687
7688 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7689 false);
7690 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7691 break;
7692 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007693 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007694 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7695 false);
7696 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007697 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7698 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007699 }
7700 case 'Y' : {
7701 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7702 break;
7703 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007704 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007705 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7706 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007707 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007708 return QualType();
7709 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007710 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007711 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007712 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007713 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007714 else
7715 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7716
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007717 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007718 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007719 return QualType();
7720 }
7721 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007722 case 'K':
7723 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7724 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7725
7726 if (Type.isNull()) {
7727 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7728 return QualType();
7729 }
7730 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007731 case 'p':
7732 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7733 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007734 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007735
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007736 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7737 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007738 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007739 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007740 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7741 case '*':
7742 case '&': {
7743 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7744 // qualified with an address space.
7745 char *End;
7746 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7747 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7748 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7749 Str = End;
7750 }
7751 if (c == '*')
7752 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7753 else
7754 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7755 break;
7756 }
7757 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7758 case 'C':
7759 Type = Type.withConst();
7760 break;
7761 case 'D':
7762 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7763 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007764 case 'R':
7765 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7766 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007767 }
7768 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007769
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007770 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007771 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007772
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007773 return Type;
7774}
7775
7776/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007777QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007778 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007779 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007780 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007781
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007782 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007783
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007784 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007785 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007786 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7787 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007788 if (Error != GE_None)
7789 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007790
7791 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7792
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007793 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007794 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007795 if (Error != GE_None)
7796 return QualType();
7797
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007798 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7799 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7800 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7801 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7802
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007803 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7804 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7805 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007806
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007807 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7808 }
7809
7810 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7811 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7812
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007813 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007814 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7815
7816 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7817
7818 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7819 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7820 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007821
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007822 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007823 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7824 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007825
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007826 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007827}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007828
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007829static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7830 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007831 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007832 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007833
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007834 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7835 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7836 case TSK_Undeclared:
7837 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7838 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7839 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007840
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007841 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007842 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007843
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00007844 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7845 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7846 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7847 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7848 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7849 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007850 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007851 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7852
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007853 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007854 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007855 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007856 }
7857
7858 if (!FD->isInlined())
7859 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007860
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007861 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7862 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00007863 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007864 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7865
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007866 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7867 // externally visible.
7868 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7869 return External;
7870
7871 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007872 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007873 }
7874
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007875 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7876 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
7877 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
7878 if (FD->getMostRecentDecl()->isMSExternInline())
7879 return GVA_StrongODR;
7880
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007881 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007882}
7883
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007884static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7885 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7886 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7887 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7888 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7889 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7890 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7891 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7892 return GVA_StrongODR;
7893 }
7894 return L;
7895}
7896
7897GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7898 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7899 FD);
7900}
7901
7902static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7903 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007904 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7905 return GVA_Internal;
7906
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007907 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
7908 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7909 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
7910 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
7911 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
7912
7913 // Let the static local variable inherit it's linkage from the nearest
7914 // enclosing function.
7915 if (LexicalContext)
7916 StaticLocalLinkage =
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007917 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007918
7919 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
7920 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
7921 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
7922 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
7923 : StaticLocalLinkage;
7924 }
7925
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00007926 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
7927 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
7928 // cause link errors.
7929 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
7930 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
7931
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00007932 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007933 case TSK_Undeclared:
7934 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7935 return GVA_StrongExternal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007936
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007937 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00007938 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007939
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007940 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7941 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7942
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00007943 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00007944 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007945 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00007946
7947 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007948}
7949
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00007950GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
7951 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
7952 VD);
7953}
7954
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007955bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007956 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7957 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7958 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00007959 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
7960 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
7961 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007962 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7963 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7964 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7965 return false;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00007966 } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
7967 return true;
7968 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007969 return false;
7970
7971 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7972 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007973 return false;
7974
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007975 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7976 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7977 return false;
7978
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007979 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7980 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7981 return true;
7982
7983 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7984 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007985 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007986 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007987
7988 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7989 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7990 return true;
7991
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007992 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7993 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7994 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7995 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7996 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7997 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7998 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7999 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8000 return true;
8001 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008002 }
8003 }
8004
8005 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8006
8007 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8008 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8009 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008010 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8011 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008012 return false;
8013 return true;
8014 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00008015
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008016 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8017 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8018
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008019 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8020 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00008021 return false;
8022
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008023 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008024 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008025 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8026 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008027 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008028
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00008029 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8030 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8031 return true;
8032
8033 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
8034 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
8035 return true;
8036
8037 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008038}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008039
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008040CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8041 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008042 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008043 if (IsCXXMethod)
8044 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00008045
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008046 return (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) ? CC_X86StdCall : CC_C;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00008047}
8048
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008049bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00008050 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8051 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8052}
8053
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00008054VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8055 if (!VTContext.get()) {
8056 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8057 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8058 else
8059 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8060 }
8061 return VTContext.get();
8062}
8063
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008064MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008065 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00008066 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008067 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8068 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8069 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00008070 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008071 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00008072 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00008073 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008074 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008075 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00008076}
8077
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00008078CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008079
8080size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00008081 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8082 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8083 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8084 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8085 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8086 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8087 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8088 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8089 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8090 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8091 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8092 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8093 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8094 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00008095}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008096
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00008097/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8098/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8099/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8100/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8101QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8102 unsigned Signed) const {
8103 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8104 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8105 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8106 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8107 return QualTy;
8108}
8109
8110/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8111/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8112/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8113QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8114 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8115 switch (Ty) {
8116 case TargetInfo::Float:
8117 return FloatTy;
8118 case TargetInfo::Double:
8119 return DoubleTy;
8120 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8121 return LongDoubleTy;
8122 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8123 return QualType();
8124 }
8125
8126 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8127}
8128
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008129void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8130 if (Number > 1)
8131 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008132}
8133
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008134unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8135 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8136 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8137 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00008138}
8139
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00008140void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8141 if (Number > 1)
8142 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8143}
8144
8145unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8146 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8147 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8148 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8149}
8150
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00008151MangleNumberingContext &
8152ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00008153 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8154 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8155 if (!MCtx)
8156 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8157 return *MCtx;
8158}
8159
8160MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8161 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008162}
8163
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008164void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8165 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8166}
8167
8168unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8169 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8170 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8171 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8172 return I->second;
8173}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008174
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008175APValue *
8176ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8177 bool MayCreate) {
8178 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8179 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8180 if (MayCreate)
8181 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8182
8183 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8184 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008185 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00008186}
8187
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008188bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8189 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8190 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8191 return false;
8192
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00008193 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8194 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8195 return false;
8196
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00008197 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8198 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8199 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8200 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8201 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8202 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8203 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8204}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008205
8206namespace {
8207
8208 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8209 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8210 ///
8211 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8212 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8213 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8214 ///
8215 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8216 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8217
8218 public:
8219 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8220 ///
8221 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8222 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8223 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8224 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8225 return Visitor.Parents;
8226 }
8227
8228 private:
8229 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8230
8231 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8232 }
8233
8234 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8235 return true;
8236 }
8237 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8238 return true;
8239 }
8240 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8241 // are not triggered during data recursion.
8242 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8243 return false;
8244 }
8245
8246 template <typename T>
8247 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00008248 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008249 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008250 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008251 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8252 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8253 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8254 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8255 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8256 // new matches.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008257 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8258 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8259 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8260 // do not have pointer identity.
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008261 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8262 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8263 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008264 } else {
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008265 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8266 auto *Node =
8267 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8268 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8269 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8270 delete Node;
8271 }
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008272 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00008273
8274 auto *Vector =
8275 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8276 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8277 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8278 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8279 // types.
8280 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8281 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8282 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8283 if (!Found)
8284 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008285 }
8286 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008287 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8288 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8289 ParentStack.pop_back();
8290 return Result;
8291 }
8292
8293 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8294 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8295 }
8296
8297 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8298 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8299 }
8300
8301 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8302 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8303
8304 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8305 };
8306
8307} // end namespace
8308
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008309ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008310ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8311 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8312 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8313 "used in the parent map.");
8314 if (!AllParents) {
8315 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8316 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8317 AllParents.reset(
8318 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8319 }
8320 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8321 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008322 return None;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008323 }
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008324 if (auto *N = I->second.dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8325 return llvm::makeArrayRef(N, 1);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00008326 }
Benjamin Kramer07935292014-10-04 17:01:26 +00008327 return *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00008328}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008329
8330bool
8331ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8332 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8333 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8334 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8335 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8336 return false;
8337 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8338 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8339 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008340 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00008341 return false;
8342
8343 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8344 return false;
8345
8346 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8347 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8348 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8349 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8350 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8351 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8352 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8353 return false;
8354 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8355 return false;
8356 }
8357 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8358
8359}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00008360
8361// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8362// doesn't include ASTContext.h
8363template
8364clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8365 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8366clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8367 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8368 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);